blob: 8b7c689ae23106e4800bedb6db51d19ed13459be [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000702/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
703/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
704static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000707 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
708 if (!DC) return true;
709
710 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
711 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
712
713 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
714 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
715
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
720/// the prospective base classes.
721static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
722 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
723 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000724 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 return false;
726
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000727 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000728 if (!RD) return false;
729 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
732 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
733 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
734 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
735 if (!BaseRT) return false;
736
737 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000738 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
739 return false;
740 }
741
742 return true;
743}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000744
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745enum IMAKind {
746 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
747 IMA_Static,
748
749 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
750 IMA_Mixed,
751
752 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
753 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
754 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
757 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
758 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
759
760 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
761 IMA_Instance,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
764 IMA_Unresolved,
765
766 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
767 /// context is not an instance method.
768 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
769
770 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
771 /// non-class context.
772 IMA_AnonymousMember,
773
774 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
775 /// context is not an instance method.
776 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
777
778 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
779 /// class.
780 IMA_Error_Unrelated
781};
782
783/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
784/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
785/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
786/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
787/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
788/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
789static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
790 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000791 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000792
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000793 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000795 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
796 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797
798 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
799 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
800
801 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
802 bool hasNonInstance = false;
803 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
804 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000805 NamedDecl *D = *I;
806 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000807 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
808
809 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
810 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
811 // that's a special case.
812 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
813 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
814 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
815 }
816 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
817 }
818 else
819 hasNonInstance = true;
820 }
821
822 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
823 // member reference.
824 if (Classes.empty())
825 return IMA_Static;
826
827 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
828 // an implicit member reference.
829 if (isStaticContext)
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
831
832 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
833 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
834 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
835 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000836 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837 Classes))
838 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
839
840 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
841}
842
843/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
844static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
845 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
846 const LookupResult &R) {
847 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
848 SourceRange Range(Loc);
849 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
850
851 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
852 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
853 if (MD->isStatic()) {
854 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
856 << Range << R.getLookupName();
857 return;
858 }
859 }
860
861 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
862 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
863 return;
864 }
865
866 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000867}
868
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
870///
871/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000872bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
873 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
875
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000876 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
879 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
883 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000884
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000885 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
886 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
887 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
888 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000889 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000890 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000891 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
892 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
893
894 if (!R.empty()) {
895 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
896 R.suppressDiagnostics();
897
898 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
899 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
900 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
901 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
902
903 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
904 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
905 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000906 if (isInstance) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000907 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000908 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000909
910 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
911 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
912 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
913 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
914 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
915 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
916 DepThisType, false);
917 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
918 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
919 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
920 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
921 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
922 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
923 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL, Name,
924 R.getNameLoc(), &TList);
925 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
926 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000928 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929
930 // Do we really want to note all of these?
931 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
932 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
933
934 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
935 return false;
936 }
937 }
938 }
939
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000940 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000941 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000942 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 if (!R.empty()) {
944 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
945 if (SS.isEmpty())
946 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
947 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
948 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
949 else
950 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
951 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
952 << SS.getRange()
953 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
954 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
955 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
956 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
957 << ND->getDeclName();
958
959 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
960 return false;
961 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000962
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
964 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
965 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
966 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
967 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
968 // to recover well anyway.
969 if (SS.isEmpty())
970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
971 else
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
973 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
974 << SS.getRange();
975
976 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
977 return true;
978 }
979 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000980 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000981 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000984 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
987 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000988 return true;
989 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000991 }
992
993 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
994 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
995 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
996 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
997 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
998 << SS.getRange();
999 return true;
1000 }
1001
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001002 // Give up, we can't recover.
1003 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1004 return true;
1005}
1006
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001007Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001008 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001009 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1010 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1011 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1012 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1013 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1014
1015 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001016 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001017
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001018 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001019
1020 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1021 DeclarationName Name;
1022 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1023 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001024 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1025 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001026
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001027 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001028
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001029 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1030 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001031 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1032 // (note: handled after lookup)
1033 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1034 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1035 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001036 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1037 // names a dependent type.
1038 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1039 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001040 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1041 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1042 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001043 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001044 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 TemplateArgs);
1046 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001047
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001048 // Perform the required lookup.
1049 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1050 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001051 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1052 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1053 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1054 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1055 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001056 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1057 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1058 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001059 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001060 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1061 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001062
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001063 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1064 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001065 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1066 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001067 if (E.isInvalid())
1068 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001069
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001070 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1071 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001072 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001073 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001074
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001075 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1076 return ExprError();
1077
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001078 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1079 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001080 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001081
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001083 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1085 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1086 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1087 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1088 }
1089
1090 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1091 // call, diagnose the problem.
1092 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001093 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001094 return ExprError();
1095
1096 assert(!R.empty() &&
1097 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001098
1099 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1100 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001101 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001102 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1103 R.clear();
1104 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1105 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1106 return move(E);
1107 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001108 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001109 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001110
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001111 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1112 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1113
1114 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001115 // Warn about constructs like:
1116 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1117 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001118 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1119 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001120 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001121 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001122 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001124 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001125 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1126 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001127 break;
1128 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001129
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001130 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1131 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001132 }
1133 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001134 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001135 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1136 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1137 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1138 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1139 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1140 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001142 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001143
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 QualType T = Func->getType();
1145 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001146 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001147 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1148 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001149 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001150 }
1151 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001152
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001153 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1154 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1155 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1156 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1157 // class member access expression.
1158 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1159 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001160 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001161 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001162 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1163 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001164 }
1165
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 if (TemplateArgs)
1167 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001168
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1170}
1171
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001172/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1173Sema::OwningExprResult
1174Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1175 LookupResult &R,
1176 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1177 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1178 case IMA_Instance:
1179 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1180
1181 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1182 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1183 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1184 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1185
1186 case IMA_Mixed:
1187 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1188 case IMA_Unresolved:
1189 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1190
1191 case IMA_Static:
1192 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1193 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1194 if (TemplateArgs)
1195 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1196 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1197
1198 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1199 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1200 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1201 return ExprError();
1202 }
1203
1204 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1205 return ExprError();
1206}
1207
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001208/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1209/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1210/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1211/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001212Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001213Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001214 DeclarationName Name,
1215 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1216 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001217 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001218 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1219
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001220 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001221 return ExprError();
1222
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001223 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1224 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1225
1226 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1227 return ExprError();
1228
1229 if (R.empty()) {
1230 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1231 return ExprError();
1232 }
1233
1234 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1235}
1236
1237/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1238/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1239/// additional lookup.
1240///
1241/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1242/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1243///
1244/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1245Sema::OwningExprResult
1246Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001247 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001248 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001249 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001250
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001251 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1252 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1253 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1254 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1255 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1256
1257 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1258 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1259 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001260 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001261
1262 bool LookForIvars;
1263 if (Lookup.empty())
1264 LookForIvars = true;
1265 else if (IsClassMethod)
1266 LookForIvars = false;
1267 else
1268 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1269 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001270 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001271 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001272 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1274 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1275 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1276 if (IsClassMethod)
1277 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1278 << IV->getDeclName());
1279
1280 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1281 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1282 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1283 return ExprError();
1284
1285 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1286 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1287 return ExprError();
1288
1289 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1290 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1291 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1292 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1293
1294 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1295 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1296 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1297 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001298 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001299 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1300 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1301 SelfName, false, false);
1302 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1303 return Owned(new (Context)
1304 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1305 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1306 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001307 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001308 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001309 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001310 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1311 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1312 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1313 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1314 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1315 }
1316 }
1317
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001318 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1319 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1320 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1321 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1322 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1323 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1324 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1325 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1326 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1327 }
1328 }
1329 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001330 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1331 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001332}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001333
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001334/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1335///
1336/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1337///
1338/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1339/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1340/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1341/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1342///
1343/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1344/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1345/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1346/// the class declaring the member.
1347///
1348/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1349/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1350/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001351bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001352Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1353 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001354 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001355 NamedDecl *Member) {
1356 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1357 if (!RD)
1358 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001359
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001360 QualType DestRecordType;
1361 QualType DestType;
1362 QualType FromRecordType;
1363 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1364 bool PointerConversions = false;
1365 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1366 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001367
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001368 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1369 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1370 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1371 PointerConversions = true;
1372 } else {
1373 DestType = DestRecordType;
1374 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001375 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001376 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1377 if (Method->isStatic())
1378 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001379
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001380 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1381 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001382
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001383 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1384 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1385 PointerConversions = true;
1386 } else {
1387 FromRecordType = FromType;
1388 DestType = DestRecordType;
1389 }
1390 } else {
1391 // No conversion necessary.
1392 return false;
1393 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001394
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001395 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1396 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001397
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001398 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1399 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1400 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001401
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001402 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1403 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1404
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001405 bool isLvalue
1406 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1407
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001408 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001409 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 // class name.
1411 //
1412 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1413 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1414 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1415 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1416 //
1417 // class Base { public: int x; };
1418 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1419 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1420 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1421 //
1422 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1423 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1424 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1425 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001426 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001427 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1428 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1429 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1430
1431 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1432
1433 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1434 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1435 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1436 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001437 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001438 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001439 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440 return true;
1441
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001442 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001443 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001444 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001445 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001446
1447 FromType = QType;
1448 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1449
1450 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1451 // we're done.
1452 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1453 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001454 }
1455 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001456
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001457 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001458
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1460 // down to the using declaration's type.
1461 //
1462 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1463 // class ever has member declarations.
1464 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1465 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1466 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1467 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1468
1469 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1470 // conversion is non-trivial.
1471 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1472 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001473 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001474 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001475 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001477
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 QualType UType = URecordType;
1479 if (PointerConversions)
1480 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001481 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001482 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001483 FromType = UType;
1484 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1485 }
1486
1487 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1488 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1489 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001490 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001492 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1493 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1494 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001495 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001496 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001497
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001498 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001499 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001500 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001501}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001502
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001503/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001504static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001505 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001506 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1507 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001508 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1509 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1510 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001511 if (SS.isSet()) {
1512 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1513 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001514 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001515
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001516 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001517 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001518}
1519
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001520/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1521/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1522/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1523/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001524Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001525Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1526 LookupResult &R,
1527 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1528 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001529 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1530
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001531 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001532
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001533 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1534 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001535 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001536 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001537 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001538 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001539 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001540
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001541 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1542 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001543 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1544 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001545 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1546 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001547 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1548 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1549 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1550 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001551 }
1552
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001553 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1554 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1555 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001556 SS,
1557 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1558 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001559}
1560
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001561bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001562 const LookupResult &R,
1563 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001564 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1565 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1566 return false;
1567
1568 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001569 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001570 return false;
1571
1572 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001573 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001574 return false;
1575
1576 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1577 // normal lookup:
1578 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1579 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1580
1581 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1582 // -- a declaration of a class member
1583 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1584 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001585 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001586 return false;
1587
1588 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1589 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1590 // using-declaration
1591 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1592 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1593 // turn off ADL anyway).
1594 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1595 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1596 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1597 return false;
1598
1599 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1600 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1601 // template
1602 // And also for builtin functions.
1603 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1604 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1605
1606 // But also builtin functions.
1607 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1608 return false;
1609 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1610 return false;
1611 }
1612
1613 return true;
1614}
1615
1616
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001617/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1618/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1619/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1620/// will in fact be used.
1621static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1622 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1623 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1624 return true;
1625 }
1626
1627 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1628 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1629 return true;
1630 }
1631
1632 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1633 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1634 return true;
1635 }
1636
1637 return false;
1638}
1639
1640Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001641Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001642 LookupResult &R,
1643 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001644 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1645 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001646 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001647 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001648
1649 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1650 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1651 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001652 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1653 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001654 return ExprError();
1655
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001656 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1657 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1658 // we've picked a target.
1659 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1660
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001661 bool Dependent
1662 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001663 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001664 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001665 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1666 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001667 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001668 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1669 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001670
1671 return Owned(ULE);
1672}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001673
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674
1675/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1676Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001677Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001678 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1679 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001680 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1681 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001682
1683 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1684 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001685
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001686 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1687 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1688 // a template argument list.
1689 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1690 << Template << SS.getRange();
1691 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1692 return ExprError();
1693 }
1694
1695 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1696 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1697 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001698 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001699 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001700 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001701 return ExprError();
1702 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001703
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001704 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1705 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1706 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1707 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001708 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001709 return ExprError();
1710
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001711 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1712 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001713 return ExprError();
1714
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001715 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1716 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1717 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1718 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001719 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001720 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1721 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1722 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001723 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001724 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001725 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1726 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1727 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1728 return ExprError();
1729 }
1730
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001731 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001732 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1733 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1734 return ExprError();
1735 }
1736
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001737 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001738 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001739 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001740 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001741 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001742 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1743 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001744 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001745
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001746 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001747 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1748 ExprTy, Loc, false,
1749 constAdded);
1750 QualType T = VD->getType();
1751 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !T->isDependentType() &&
1752 !T->isReferenceType()) {
1753 Expr *E = new (Context)
1754 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1755 SourceLocation());
1756
1757 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001758 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
1759 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001760 SourceLocation(),
1761 Owned(E));
1762 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001763 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001764 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian8e739282010-06-08 17:52:11 +00001765 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001766 }
1767 }
1768 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001769 }
1770 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1771 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001772
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001773 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001774}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001775
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001776Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1777 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001778 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001779
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001780 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001781 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001782 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1783 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1784 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001785 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001786
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001787 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1788 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001789
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001790 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1791 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001792 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001793 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001794 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001795
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001796 QualType ResTy;
1797 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1798 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1799 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001800 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001802 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001803 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001804 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1805 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001806 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001807}
1808
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001809Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001810 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001811 bool Invalid = false;
1812 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1813 if (Invalid)
1814 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001816 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1817 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001818 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001819 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001820
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001821 QualType Ty;
1822 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1823 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1824 else if (Literal.isWide())
1825 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001826 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1827 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001828 else
1829 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001830
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001831 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1832 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001833 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001834}
1835
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001836Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1837 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001838 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1839 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001840 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001841 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001842 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001843 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001844 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001845
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001846 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001847 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1848 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001849 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001850
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001851 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001852 bool Invalid = false;
1853 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1854 if (Invalid)
1855 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001856
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001858 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001859 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001860 return ExprError();
1861
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001862 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001863
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001864 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001865 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001866 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001867 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001868 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001869 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001870 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001871 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001872
1873 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1874
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001875 using llvm::APFloat;
1876 APFloat Val(Format);
1877
1878 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001879
1880 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1881 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1882 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1883 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001884 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001885 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001886 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001887 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001888 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1889 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001890 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001891 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1892 }
1893
1894 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1895 << Ty
1896 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1897 }
1898
1899 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001900 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001901
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001902 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001903 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001904 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001905 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001906
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001907 // long long is a C99 feature.
1908 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001909 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001910 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1911
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001912 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001913 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001915 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1916 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1917 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001918 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1919 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001920 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001921 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1923 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001924
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1926 // be an unsigned int.
1927 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1928
1929 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001931 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1932 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001933 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001935 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1936 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1937 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1938 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001939 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001941 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001942 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001944 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001945
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001946 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001947 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001948 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001949
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001950 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1951 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1952 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1953 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001954 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001956 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001957 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959 }
1960
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001964
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001965 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1966 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1967 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1968 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001969 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001970 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001971 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001972 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001973 }
1974 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001976 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1977 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001978 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001979 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001980 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001981 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001982 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001983
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001984 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1985 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001986 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001987 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001988 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001989
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001990 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1991 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001992 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001993 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994
1995 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001996}
1997
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001998Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1999 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002000 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002001 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002002 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002003}
2004
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002005/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002006/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002007bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002008 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2009 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2010 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002011 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2012 return false;
2013
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002014 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2015 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2016 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2017 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2018 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2019 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2020
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002021 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002022 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002024 if (isSizeof)
2025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2026 return false;
2027 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002028
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002029 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002030 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2032 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002033 return false;
2034 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002035
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002037 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2038 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002039 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002040
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002041 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002042 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002043 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002044 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2045 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002046 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002047
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002048 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2049 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2050 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2051 return true;
2052 }
2053
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002054 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002055}
2056
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002057bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2058 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2059 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002060
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002061 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2063 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002064
2065 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2066 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2067 return false;
2068
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002069 if (E->getBitField()) {
2070 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2071 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002072 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002073
2074 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2075 // bit-field.
2076 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002077 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002078 return false;
2079
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002080 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2081}
2082
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002083/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002084Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002085Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002086 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002087 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002088 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 return ExprError();
2090
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002091 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002092
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002093 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2094 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2095 return ExprError();
2096
2097 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002098 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002099 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2100 R.getEnd()));
2101}
2102
2103/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2104/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002105Action::OwningExprResult
2106Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002107 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2108 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2109 bool isInvalid = false;
2110 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2111 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2112 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2113 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002114 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2116 isInvalid = true;
2117 } else {
2118 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2119 }
2120
2121 if (isInvalid)
2122 return ExprError();
2123
2124 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2125 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2126 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2127 R.getEnd()));
2128}
2129
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002130/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2131/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2132/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002133Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002134Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2135 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002136 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002137 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002138
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002139 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002140 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2141 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2142 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002144
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002145 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2146 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2147 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2148
2149 if (Result.isInvalid())
2150 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2151
2152 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002153}
2154
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002155QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002156 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2157 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002159 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002160 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002161 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002163 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2164 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2165 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002166
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002167 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002168 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2169 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002170 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002171}
2172
2173
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002174
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002175Action::OwningExprResult
2176Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2177 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002178 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2179 switch (Kind) {
2180 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2181 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2182 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2183 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002184
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002185 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002186}
2187
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188Action::OwningExprResult
2189Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2190 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002191 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2192 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2193
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002194 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2195 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002196
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002197 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002198 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2199 Base.release();
2200 Idx.release();
2201 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2202 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2203 }
2204
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002205 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002206 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002207 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2208 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2209 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002210 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002211 }
2212
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002213 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2214}
2215
2216
2217Action::OwningExprResult
2218Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2219 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2220 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2221 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2222
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002224 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2225 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2226 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002227
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002229
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002230 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002231 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002232 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002233 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002234 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2235 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002236 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2237 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2238 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2239 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002240 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002241 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2242 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002243 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002244 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002245 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2247 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002248 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002249 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002250 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002251 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2252 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2253 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002254 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002255 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002256 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2257 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2258 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2259 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002260 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002261 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002262 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002263
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002264 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2265 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002266 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2267 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002268 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2270 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2271 // force the promotion here.
2272 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2273 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002274 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2275 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002276 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2277
2278 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2279 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002280 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002281 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2282 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2283 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2284 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002285 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2286 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002287 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2288
2289 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2290 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002291 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002292 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002293 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2294 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002295 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002296 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002297 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2298 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002299 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2300 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002301
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002302 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002303 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2304 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002305 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2306
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002307 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2309 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002310 // incomplete types are not object types.
2311 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2312 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2313 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2314 return ExprError();
2315 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002317 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002319 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2320 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002321 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002322
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002323 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002324 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002325 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2326 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2327 return ExprError();
2328 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002329
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002330 Base.release();
2331 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002332 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002333 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002334}
2335
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002336QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002337CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002338 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002339 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002340 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2341 // see FIXME there.
2342 //
2343 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2344 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002345 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002346
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002347 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002348 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002349
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002350 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002351 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2352 // to be selected.
2353 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002354
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2356 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002357 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002358
2359 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2360 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002361 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002362 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2363 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002364 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002365 do
2366 compStr++;
2367 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002369 do
2370 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002372 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002373
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002374 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002375 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2376 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002377 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2378 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002379 return QualType();
2380 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002381
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002382 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2383 // operates on.
2384 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002385 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002386
2387 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002388 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002389
2390 while (*compStr) {
2391 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2392 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2393 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2394 return QualType();
2395 }
2396 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002397 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002398
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002399 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002400 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002401 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002402 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002403 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002404 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002405 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002406 if (HexSwizzle)
2407 CompSize--;
2408
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002409 if (CompSize == 1)
2410 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002411
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002412 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002413 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002414 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2415 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2416 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2417 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002418 }
2419 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002420}
2421
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002422static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002423 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002424 const Selector &Sel,
2425 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002426
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002427 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002428 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002429 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002431
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2433 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002434 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002435 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002436 return D;
2437 }
2438 return 0;
2439}
2440
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002441static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002442 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002443 const Selector &Sel,
2444 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002445 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2446 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002447 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002448 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002449 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002450 GDecl = PD;
2451 break;
2452 }
2453 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002454 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002455 GDecl = OMD;
2456 break;
2457 }
2458 }
2459 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002460 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002461 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2462 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002463 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002464 if (GDecl)
2465 return GDecl;
2466 }
2467 }
2468 return GDecl;
2469}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002470
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002471Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002472Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2473 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002474 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2475 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2476 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2477 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2478 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2479
2480 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2481 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2482 //
2483 // T* t;
2484 // t.f;
2485 //
2486 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2487 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2488 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2489 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002490 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002491 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2492 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002493 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002494 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002495 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 return ExprError();
2497 }
2498 }
2499
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002500 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002501 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002502
2503 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2504 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002505 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002506 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2507 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2508 SS.getRange(),
2509 FirstQualifierInScope,
2510 Name, NameLoc,
2511 TemplateArgs));
2512}
2513
2514/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2515/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2516/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2517static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2518 Expr *BaseExpr,
2519 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002520 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002521 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002522 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2523 // diagnostics.
2524 if (!BaseExpr)
2525 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002526
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002527 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2528 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002529}
2530
2531// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2532// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2533// type. The restriction here is:
2534//
2535// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2536// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2537// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2538//
2539// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2540// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2541// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2542// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2543bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2544 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002545 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002546 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002547 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2548 if (!BaseRT) {
2549 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2550 // dependent.
2551 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2552 return false;
2553 }
2554 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002555
2556 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2558 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002559 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002560 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002561
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002562 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2563 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2564 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2565 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2566
2567 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2568 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2569
2570 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2571 return false;
2572 }
2573
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002574 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002575 return true;
2576}
2577
2578static bool
2579LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2580 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002581 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2582 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002583 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2584 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002585 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002586 << BaseRange))
2587 return true;
2588
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002589 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2590 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2591 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2592
2593 bool MOUS;
2594 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2595 return false;
2596 }
2597
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002598 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2599 if (SS.isSet()) {
2600 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2601 // nested-name-specifier.
2602 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2603
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002604 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002605 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2606 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2607 return true;
2608 }
2609
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002610 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002611
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002612 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2613 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2614 << DC << SS.getRange();
2615 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 }
2617 }
2618
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002619 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2620 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002622 if (!R.empty())
2623 return false;
2624
2625 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2626 // for typos.
2627 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002628 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002629 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002630 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2631 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2632 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002633 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2634 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002635 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2636 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2637 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002638 return false;
2639 } else {
2640 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002641 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002642 }
2643
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002644 return false;
2645}
2646
2647Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002648Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002649 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002650 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002651 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2652 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2653 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2654 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2655
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002656 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2657 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002658 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002659 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2660 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2661 Name, NameLoc,
2662 TemplateArgs);
2663
2664 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002665
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 // Implicit member accesses.
2667 if (!Base) {
2668 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2669 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2670 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2671 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002672 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002673 return ExprError();
2674
2675 // Explicit member accesses.
2676 } else {
2677 OwningExprResult Result =
2678 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002679 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680
2681 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2682 Owned(Base);
2683 return ExprError();
2684 }
2685
2686 if (Result.get())
2687 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002688
2689 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2690 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002691 }
2692
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002693 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002694 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2695 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002696}
2697
2698Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002699Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2700 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2701 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002702 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002703 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002704 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2705 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002708 if (IsArrow) {
2709 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2710 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2711 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002712 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713
2714 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2715 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2716 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2717 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2718
2719 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002720 return ExprError();
2721
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002722 if (R.empty()) {
2723 // Rederive where we looked up.
2724 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2725 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2726 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002727
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002729 << MemberName << DC
2730 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002731 return ExprError();
2732 }
2733
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002734 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2735 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2736 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2737 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2738 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2739 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2740 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2741 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2742 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2743 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002744 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002745 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002746 return ExprError();
2747
2748 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2749 // result.
2750 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002751 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002752 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002753 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002754 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002755
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002756 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2757 // pick a member.
2758 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2759
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2761 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2762 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002763 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2764 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2766 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002767 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002768
2769 return Owned(MemExpr);
2770 }
2771
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002772 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002773 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2775
2776 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2777
2778 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2779 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2780 // error cases.
2781 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2782 return ExprError();
2783
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002784 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2785 if (!BaseExpr) {
2786 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002787 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002788 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2789
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002790 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2791 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2792 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2793 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002794 }
2795
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002796 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2797 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2798 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2799 // explicitly qualified.
2800 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2801 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2802 }
2803
2804 // Check the use of this member.
2805 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2806 Owned(BaseExpr);
2807 return ExprError();
2808 }
2809
2810 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2811 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2812 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002813 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2814 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002815 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2816 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2817
2818 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2819 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2820 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2821 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2822 else {
2823 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2824 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2825 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2826
2827 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2828 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2829
2830 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2831 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2832 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2833 }
2834
2835 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002836 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837 return ExprError();
2838 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002839 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002840 }
2841
2842 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2843 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2844 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002845 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002846 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2847 }
2848
2849 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2850 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2851 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002852 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853 MemberFn->getType()));
2854 }
2855
2856 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2857 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2858 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002859 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002860 }
2861
2862 Owned(BaseExpr);
2863
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002864 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002865 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002866 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2867 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2868 else
2869 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2870 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002872 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2873 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002874 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002875 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002876}
2877
2878/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2879/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2880/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2881/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2882/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2883/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2884/// an ordinary member expression.
2885///
2886/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2887/// fixed for ObjC++.
2888Sema::OwningExprResult
2889Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002890 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002891 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002892 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002893 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002894
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002895 // Perform default conversions.
2896 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002897
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002898 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002899 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2900
2901 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2902 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002903
2904 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002906 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2907 // call, and continue on.
2908 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2909 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2910 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2911 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2912 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002913 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2914 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002915 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2916 ->isRecordType()))) {
2917 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2918 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2919 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002920 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002921
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002922 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002923 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002924 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002925 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002926 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002928
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002929 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2930 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2931 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2932 }
2933 }
2934 }
2935
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002936 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2937 // use that.
2938 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002939 if (IsArrow) {
2940 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2941 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2942 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002943 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002944 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002945 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2946 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002947 }
2948 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002949 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2950 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2951 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2952 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002953 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002954 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002955 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002956
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002957 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2958 // use that.
2959 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2960 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2961 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2962 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2963 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2964 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2965 }
2966 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002967
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002968 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002969
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002970 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002971 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002972 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2973 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2974 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2975 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2976 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2977 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2978 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2979 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2980 // Check the use of this method.
2981 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2982 return ExprError();
2983 }
2984 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2985 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2986 Selector SetterSel =
2987 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2988 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2989 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2990 if (!Setter) {
2991 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2992 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002993 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002994 }
2995 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2996 if (!Setter)
2997 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002998
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002999 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3000 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003001
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003002 if (Getter || Setter) {
3003 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003004
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003005 if (Getter)
3006 PType = Getter->getResultType();
3007 else
3008 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3009 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3010 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003011 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003012 PType,
3013 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3014 }
3015 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3016 << MemberName << BaseType);
3017 }
3018 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003019
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003020 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3021 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3022 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003023 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003024 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003025
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003026 if (IsArrow) {
3027 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003028 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003029 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3030 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003031 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3032 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3033 // struct MyRecord foo;
3034 // foo->bar
3035 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3036 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3037 // by now.
3038 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3039 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003040 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003041 IsArrow = false;
3042 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003043 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3044 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3045 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003046 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003047 } else {
3048 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3049 // type *foo;
3050 // foo.bar
3051 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3052 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3053 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3054 // the appropriate pointer type
3055 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3056 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3057 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3058 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3059 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003060 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003061 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3062 IsArrow = true;
3063 }
3064 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003065 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003066
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003067 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003068 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003069 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003070 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003071 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003073 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003074
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003075 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3076 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003077 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003078 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003079 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003080 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3081 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3082 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3083 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003084 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3085
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003086 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003087 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003088
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003089 if (!IV) {
3090 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3091 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3092 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003093 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003094 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003095 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003096 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3097 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003098 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3099 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003100 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003101 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003102 } else {
3103 Res.clear();
3104 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003105 }
3106 }
3107
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003108 if (IV) {
3109 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3110 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3111 // error cases.
3112 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3113 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003114
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003115 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3116 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3117 return ExprError();
3118 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3119 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3120 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3121 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3122 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3123 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3124 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3125 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3126 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3127 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3128 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3129 // AST for a function decl.
3130 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003131 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003132 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3133 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3134 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3135 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3136 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3137 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003138
3139 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3140 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003141 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003142 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003143 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003144 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3145 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003146 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003147 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003148 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003149
3150 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3151 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003152 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003153 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003154 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003155 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003156 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003157 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003158 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003159 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003160 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3161 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003162 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003163 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003164
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003165 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003166 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003167 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3168 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3169 // Check the use of this declaration
3170 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3171 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003172
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003173 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3174 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3175 }
3176 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3177 // Check the use of this method.
3178 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3179 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003180
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003181 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003182 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3183 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3184 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003185 }
3186 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003187
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003188 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003189 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003190 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003191
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003192 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3193 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003194 if (!IsArrow)
3195 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3196 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003197 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003198
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003199 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003200 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003201 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3202 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003203 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003204 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003205 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003206
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003207 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003208 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003209 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003210 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3211 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003212 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003213 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003214 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003215 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003216
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003217 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3218 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3219
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003220 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003221}
3222
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003223/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3224/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3225/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3226/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3227/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3228///
3229/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3230/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3231/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3232/// only be called
3233/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3234/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3235/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3236Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3237 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3238 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003239 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003240 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3241 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3242 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3243 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3244 return ExprError();
3245
3246 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3247
3248 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3249 DeclarationName Name;
3250 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3251 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3252 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3253 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3254
3255 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3256
3257 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3258 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3259 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3260
3261 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3262 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3263
3264 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3265 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003266 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3267 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003268 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3270 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3271 Name, NameLoc,
3272 TemplateArgs);
3273 } else {
3274 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003275 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3276 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003277
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003278 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3279 Owned(Base);
3280 return ExprError();
3281 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003282
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003283 if (Result.get()) {
3284 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3285 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3286 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3287 // call now.
3288 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3289 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3290 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003291
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003292 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003293 }
3294
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003295 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003296 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3297 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298 }
3299
3300 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003301}
3302
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003303Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3304 FunctionDecl *FD,
3305 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3306 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3307 Diag (CallLoc,
3308 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3309 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003310 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003311 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3312 } else {
3313 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3314 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3315
3316 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003317 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3318 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003319
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003320 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3321 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003322 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003323
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003324 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003325 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003326 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003327
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003328 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3329 InitializedEntity Entity
3330 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3331 InitializationKind Kind
3332 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3333 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3334 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3335
3336 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003337 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003338 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3339 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003340 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003341
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003342 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003343 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003344 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003345 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003346
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003347 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3348 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3349 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003350 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3351 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003352 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3353 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003354 }
3355
3356 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003357 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003358}
3359
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003360/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3361/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3362/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3363/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3364/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3365/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003366bool
3367Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003368 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003369 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003370 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3371 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003372 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003373 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3374 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003375 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003376
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003377 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3378 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3379 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3380 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3381 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003382 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003383 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003384 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003385 }
3386
3387 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3388 // them.
3389 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3390 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3391 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3392 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003393 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003394 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003395 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3396 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3397 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003398 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003399 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003400 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003401 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003402 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003403 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003404 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3405 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3406 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3407 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3408 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003409 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003410 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003411 if (Invalid)
3412 return true;
3413 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3414 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3415 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003416
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417 return false;
3418}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003419
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003420bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3421 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3422 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3423 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3424 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3425 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003426 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003427 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3428 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3429 bool Invalid = false;
3430 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3431 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3432 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3433 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003434 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003435 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003436 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003437
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003439 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3440 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003441
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003442 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3443 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003444 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003445 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003446 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003447
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003448 // Pass the argument
3449 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3450 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3451 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003452
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003453
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003454 InitializedEntity Entity =
3455 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3456 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3457 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3458 SourceLocation(),
3459 Owned(Arg));
3460 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3461 return true;
3462
3463 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003464 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003465 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003466
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003467 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003468 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003469 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3470 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003471
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003472 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003473 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003474 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003475 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003476
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003477 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003478 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003479 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003480 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003481 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003482 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003483 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 }
3485 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003486 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487}
3488
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003489/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003490/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3491/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003492Action::OwningExprResult
3493Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3494 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003495 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003496 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003497
3498 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3499 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003500
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003501 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003502 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003503 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003504
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003505 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003506 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3507 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3508 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3509 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3510 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003511 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003512 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3513 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003514
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003515 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3516 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003517
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003518 NumArgs = 0;
3519 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003520
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003521 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3522 RParenLoc));
3523 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003524
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003525 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003526 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003527 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3528 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003529 bool Dependent = false;
3530 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3531 Dependent = true;
3532 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3533 Dependent = true;
3534
3535 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003536 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003537 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3538
3539 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3540 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3541 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3542 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3543
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003544 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3545
3546 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3547 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3548 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3549 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3550 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3551 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3552 // method template.
3553 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003554 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3555 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003556 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003557
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003558 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3559 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003560 }
3561
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003562 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003563 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003564 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003565 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003566 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3567 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003568 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003569
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003570 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003571 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003572 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3573 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003574 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3575 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003576 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003577
3578 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3579 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003580 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3581 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003582
3583 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3584 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003585 TheCall.get(), 0))
3586 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003587
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003589 RParenLoc))
3590 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003591
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003592 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3593 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003594 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003595 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3596 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003597 }
3598 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003599 }
3600
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003601 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003602 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003603 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003604
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003605 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003606 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3607 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003608 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003609 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003610 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003611
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003612 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3613 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3614 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3615
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003616 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3617}
3618
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003619/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3620/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003621/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3622/// block-pointer type.
3623///
3624/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3625Sema::OwningExprResult
3626Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3627 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3628 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3629 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3630 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3631
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003632 // Promote the function operand.
3633 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3634
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003635 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3636 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003637 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3638 Args, NumArgs,
3639 Context.BoolTy,
3640 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003641
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003642 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3643 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3644 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3645 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003646 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003647 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003648 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3649 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003650 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003651 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003652 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003653 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003654 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003655 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003656 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3657 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3658
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003659 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003660 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003661 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3662 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003663 return ExprError();
3664
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003665 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003666 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003667
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003668 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003669 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003670 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003671 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003672 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003673 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003674
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003675 if (FDecl) {
3676 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3677 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3678 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003679 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003680 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003681 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003682 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3683 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3684 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3685 }
3686 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003687 }
3688
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003689 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003690 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3691 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3692 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003693 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3694 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003695 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3696 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003697 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003698 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003699 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003700 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003701
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003702 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3703 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003704 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3705 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003706
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003707 // Check for sentinels
3708 if (NDecl)
3709 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003710
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003711 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003712 if (FDecl) {
3713 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3714 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003715
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003716 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003717 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3718 } else if (NDecl) {
3719 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3720 return ExprError();
3721 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003722
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003723 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003724}
3725
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003726Action::OwningExprResult
3727Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3728 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003729 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003730 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003731 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003732
3733 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3734 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3735 if (!TInfo)
3736 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3737
3738 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3739}
3740
3741Action::OwningExprResult
3742Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3743 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3744 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003745 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003746
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003747 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003748 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003749 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3750 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003751 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3752 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003753 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003754 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003755 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003756 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003757
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003758 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003759 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003760 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003761 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003762 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003763 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3764 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3765 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3766 &literalType);
3767 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003768 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003769 InitExpr.release();
3770 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003771
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003772 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003773 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003774 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003775 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003776 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003777
3778 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003779
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003780 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003781 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003782}
3783
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003784Action::OwningExprResult
3785Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003786 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3787 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3788 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003789
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003790 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003791 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003792
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003793 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3794 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003795 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003796 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003797}
3798
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003799static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3800 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003801 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003802 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3803
3804 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3805 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003806 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3807 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003808 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003809 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3810 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3811 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003812
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003813 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3814 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3815 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3816 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3817 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3818 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3819 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3820 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003821
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003822 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3823 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3824 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3825 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3826 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3827 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003828
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003829 // FIXME: Assert here.
3830 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3831 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3832}
3833
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003834/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003835bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003836 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003837 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003838 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003839 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003840 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3841 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003842
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003843 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003844
3845 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3846 // type needs to be scalar.
3847 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3848 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003849 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3850 return false;
3851 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003852
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003853 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003854 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003855 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3856 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003857 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003858 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3859 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003860 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003861 return false;
3862 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003863
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003864 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003865 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003866 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003867 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003868 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003869 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003870 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003871 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003872 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3873 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3874 break;
3875 }
3876 }
3877 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3878 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3879 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003880 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003881 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003882 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003883
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003884 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3885 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3886 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3887 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003888
3889 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003890 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003891 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3892 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003893 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003894 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003895
3896 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003897 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003898
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003899 if (castType->isVectorType())
3900 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3901 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3902 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3903
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003904 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3905 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003906
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003907 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003908 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003909 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003910 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003911 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3912 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3913 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3914 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003915 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003916 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3917 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3918 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003919 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920
3921 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003922 return false;
3923}
3924
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003925bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3926 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003927 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003928
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003929 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003930 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003931 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003932 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003933 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003934 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003935 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003936 } else
3937 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003938 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003939 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003940
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003941 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003942 return false;
3943}
3944
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003945bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003946 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003947 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003948
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003949 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003950
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003951 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3952 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003953 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3954 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3955 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3956 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003957 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003958 return false;
3959 }
3960
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003961 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003962 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3963 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003964 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3965 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3966 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3967 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003968
3969 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3970 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3971 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003972
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003973 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003974 return false;
3975}
3976
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003977Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003978Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003979 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3980 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3981 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003982
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003983 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3984 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3985 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003986 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003987
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003988 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003989 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003990 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003991 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3992 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003993
3994 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3995}
3996
3997Action::OwningExprResult
3998Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3999 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4000 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4001
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004002 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004003 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004004 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004005 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004006 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004007
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004008 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004009 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004010 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004011 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004012}
4013
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004014/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4015/// of comma binary operators.
4016Action::OwningExprResult
4017Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4018 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4019 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4020 if (!E)
4021 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004022
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004023 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004024
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004025 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4026 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4027 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004028
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004029 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4030}
4031
4032Action::OwningExprResult
4033Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4034 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004035 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004036 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004037 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004038 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004039
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004040 // Check for an altivec literal,
4041 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004042 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4043 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4044 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4045 return ExprError();
4046 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004047 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4048 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4049 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4050 }
4051 else
4052 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4053 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004055 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4056 // then handle it as such.
4057 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004058 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4059 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4060 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4061
4062 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4063 // braces instead of the original commas.
4064 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004065 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4066 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004067 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4068 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004069 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004070 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004071 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004072 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4073 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004074 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004075 }
4076}
4077
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004078Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004079 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004080 MultiExprArg Val,
4081 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004082 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4083 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004084 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4085 Expr *expr;
4086 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4087 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4088 else
4089 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004090 return Owned(expr);
4091}
4092
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004093/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4094/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004095/// C99 6.5.15
4096QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4097 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004098 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4099 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4100 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4101
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004102 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4103 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4104 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4105 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4106 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4107 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004108
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004109 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004110 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4111 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4112 << CondTy;
4113 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004114 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004115
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004116 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004117 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4118 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004119
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004120 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4121 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004122 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4123 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4124 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004125 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004126
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004127 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4128 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004129 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4130 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004131 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004132 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004133 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004134 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004135 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004136 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004137
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004138 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004139 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004140 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4141 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4142 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4143 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4144 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4145 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4146 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004147 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4148 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004149 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004150 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004151 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4152 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004153 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004154 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004155 // promote the null to a pointer.
4156 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004157 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004158 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004159 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004160 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004161 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004162 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004163 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004164
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004165 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4166 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4167 QuestionLoc);
4168 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4169 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004170
4171
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004172 // Handle block pointer types.
4173 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4174 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4175 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4176 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004177 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4178 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 return destType;
4180 }
4181 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004182 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004183 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004184 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004185 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4186 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4187 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004188 return LHSTy;
4189 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004190 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004191 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4192 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004193
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004194 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4195 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004196 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004197 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004198 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4199 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4200 // to get a consistent AST.
4201 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004202 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4203 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004204 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004205 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004206 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004207 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4208 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004209 return LHSTy;
4210 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004211
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004212 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4213 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4214 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004215 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4216 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004217
4218 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4219 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4220 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004221 QualType destPointee
4222 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004223 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004224 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4225 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4226 // Promote to void*.
4227 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004228 return destType;
4229 }
4230 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004231 QualType destPointee
4232 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004233 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004234 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004235 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004236 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004237 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004238 return destType;
4239 }
4240
4241 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4242 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4243 return LHSTy;
4244 }
4245 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4246 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4247 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4248 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4249 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4250 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4251 // to get a consistent AST.
4252 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004253 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4254 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004255 return incompatTy;
4256 }
4257 // The pointer types are compatible.
4258 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4259 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4260 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4261 // type.
4262 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4263 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004264 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4265 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004266 return LHSTy;
4267 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004268
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004269 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4270 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4271 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4272 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004273 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004274 return RHSTy;
4275 }
4276 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4277 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4278 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004279 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004280 return LHSTy;
4281 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004282
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004283 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004284 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4285 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004286 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004287}
4288
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004289/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4290/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4291QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4292 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4293 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4294 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004295
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004296 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4297 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4298 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4299 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4300 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4301 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4302 return LHSTy;
4303 }
4304 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4305 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4306 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4307 return RHSTy;
4308 }
4309 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4310 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4311 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4312 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4313 return LHSTy;
4314 }
4315 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4316 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4317 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4318 return RHSTy;
4319 }
4320 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4321 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4322 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4323 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4324 return LHSTy;
4325 }
4326 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4327 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4328 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4329 return RHSTy;
4330 }
4331 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4332 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004333
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004334 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4335 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4336 return LHSTy;
4337 }
4338 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4339 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4340 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004341
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004342 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4343 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4344 // type. This allows
4345 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4346 // where B is a subclass of A.
4347 //
4348 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4349 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4350 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4351 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004352
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004353 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4354 // It could return the composite type.
4355 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4356 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4357 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4358 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4359 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4360 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4361 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4362 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4363 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4364 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4365 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4366 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4367 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4368 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004369 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004370 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4371 ;
4372 else {
4373 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4374 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4375 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4376 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4377 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4379 return incompatTy;
4380 }
4381 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4382 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4383 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4384 return compositeType;
4385 }
4386 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4387 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4388 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4389 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4390 QualType destPointee
4391 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4392 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4393 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4394 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4395 // Promote to void*.
4396 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4397 return destType;
4398 }
4399 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4400 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4401 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4402 QualType destPointee
4403 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4404 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4405 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4406 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4407 // Promote to void*.
4408 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4409 return destType;
4410 }
4411 return QualType();
4412}
4413
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004414/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004415/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004416Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4417 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4418 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4419 ExprArg RHS) {
4420 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4421 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004422
4423 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4424 // was the condition.
4425 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4426 if (isLHSNull)
4427 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004428
4429 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004430 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004431 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004432 return ExprError();
4433
4434 Cond.release();
4435 LHS.release();
4436 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004437 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004438 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004439 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004440}
4441
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004442// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004443// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004444// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4445// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4446// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004447Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004448Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004449 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004450
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004451 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4452 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4453 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4454 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4455 return Compatible;
4456 }
4457
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004458 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004459 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4460 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004461
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004462 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004463 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4464 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004465
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004466 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004467
4468 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4469 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4470 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004471 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004472 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004473 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004474
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004475 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4476 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004477 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004478 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004479 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004480 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004481
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004482 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004483 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4484 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004485 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004486
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004487 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004488 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004489 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004490
4491 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004492 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4493 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004494 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004495 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004496 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004497 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4498 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4499 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4500 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4501 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4502 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004503 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004504 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004505 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004506 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004507
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004508 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004509 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004510 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004511 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004512
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004513 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4514 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4515 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4516 // warning can be disabled.
4517 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4518 return ConvTy;
4519 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4520 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004521
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004522 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4523 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4524 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4525 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4526 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4527 do {
4528 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4529 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004530
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004531 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4532 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4533 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004534
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004535 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004536 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004537 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004538
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004539 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004540 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004541 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004542 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004543}
4544
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004545/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4546/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4547/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4548// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004549Sema::AssignConvertType
4550Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004551 QualType rhsType) {
4552 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004553
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004554 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004555 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4556 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004558 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4559 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4560 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004561
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004562 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004563
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004564 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004565 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004566 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004567
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004568 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4569 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4570 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4571 }
4572 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004573 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004574 return ConvTy;
4575}
4576
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004577/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4578/// for assignment compatibility.
4579Sema::AssignConvertType
4580Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004581 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4582 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004583 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4584 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004585 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004586 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004587 }
4588 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4589 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004590 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4591 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004592 return IncompatiblePointer;
4593 return Compatible;
4594 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004595 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004596 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004597 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004598 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4599 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4600 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4601 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4602 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4603 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004604
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004605 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4606 return Compatible;
4607 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4608 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004609 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004610}
4611
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004612/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4613/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004614/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4615///
4616/// int a, *pint;
4617/// short *pshort;
4618/// struct foo *pfoo;
4619///
4620/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4621/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4622/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4623/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4624///
4625/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004626/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004627///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004628Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004629Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004630 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4631 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004632 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4633 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004634
4635 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004636 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004637
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004638 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4639 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4640 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4641 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4642 return Compatible;
4643 }
4644
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004645 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4646 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4647 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4648 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4649 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4650 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4651 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004652 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004653 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004654 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004655 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004656 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004657 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4658 // to the same ExtVector type.
4659 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4660 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4661 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004662 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004663 return Compatible;
4664 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004665
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004666 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004667 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004668 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004669 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004670 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4671 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004672 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004673 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004674 }
4675 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004676 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004677
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004678 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4679 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004680 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004681
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004682 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004683 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004684 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004685
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004686 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004687 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004688
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004689 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004690 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004691 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4692 return Compatible;
4693 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004694 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004695 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4696 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004697 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004698
4699 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004700 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004701 return Compatible;
4702 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004703 return Incompatible;
4704 }
4705
4706 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4707 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004708 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004709
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004710 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004711 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004712 return Compatible;
4713
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004714 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4715 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004716
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004717 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004718 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004719 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004720 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004721 return Incompatible;
4722 }
4723
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004724 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4725 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4726 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004727
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004728 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004729 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004730 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4731 return Compatible;
4732 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004733 }
4734 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004735 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004736 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004737 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004738 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4739 return Compatible;
4740 }
4741 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4742 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4743 return Compatible;
4744 return Incompatible;
4745 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004746 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004747 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004748 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4749 return Compatible;
4750
4751 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004752 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004753
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004754 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004755 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004756
4757 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004758 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004759 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004760 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004761 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004762 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4763 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4764 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4765 return Compatible;
4766
4767 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4768 return PointerToInt;
4769
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004770 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004771 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004772 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4773 return Compatible;
4774 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004775 }
4776 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004777 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004778 return Compatible;
4779 return Incompatible;
4780 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004781
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004782 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004783 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004784 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004785 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004786 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004787}
4788
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004789/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4790/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004791static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004792 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4793 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4794 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004795 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004796 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004797 SourceLocation());
4798 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4799 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4800
4801 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4802 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004803 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004804 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004805 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004806}
4807
4808Sema::AssignConvertType
4809Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4810 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4811
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004812 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004813 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4814 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004815 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004816 return Incompatible;
4817
4818 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4819 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4820 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4821 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004822 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4823 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004824 it != itend; ++it) {
4825 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4826 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4827 // 1) void pointer
4828 // 2) null pointer constant
4829 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004830 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004831 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004832 InitField = *it;
4833 break;
4834 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004835
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004836 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004837 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004838 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004839 InitField = *it;
4840 break;
4841 }
4842 }
4843
4844 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4845 == Compatible) {
4846 InitField = *it;
4847 break;
4848 }
4849 }
4850
4851 if (!InitField)
4852 return Incompatible;
4853
4854 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4855 return Compatible;
4856}
4857
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004858Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004859Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004860 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4861 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4862 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4863 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4864 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004865 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004866 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004867 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004868 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004869 }
4870
4871 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4872 // structures.
4873 }
4874
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004875 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4876 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004877 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4878 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004879 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004880 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004881 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004882 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004883 return Compatible;
4884 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004885
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004886 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004887 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004888 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004889 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004890 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004891 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004892 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004893 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004894
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004895 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4896 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004897
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004898 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4899 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004900 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4901 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4902 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4903 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004904 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004905 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4906 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004907 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004908}
4909
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004910QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004911 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004912 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004913 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004914 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004915}
4916
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004917QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004918 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004919 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004920 QualType lhsType =
4921 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4922 QualType rhsType =
4923 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004924
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004925 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004926 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004927 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004928
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004929 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4930 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004931 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4932 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004933 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4934 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004935 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004936 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004937 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4938 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4939 return lhsType;
4940 }
4941
4942 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4943 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004944 }
4945 }
4946 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004947
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004948 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4949 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4950 bool swapped = false;
4951 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4952 swapped = true;
4953 std::swap(rex, lex);
4954 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4955 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004956
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004957 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004958 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004959 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004960 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004961 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004962 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004963 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4964 return lhsType;
4965 }
4966 }
4967 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4968 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4969 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004970 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004971 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4972 return lhsType;
4973 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004974 }
4975 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004976
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004977 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004978 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004979 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004980 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004981 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004982}
4983
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004984QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4985 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004986 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004987 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004988
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004989 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004990
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004991 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4992 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4993 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004994
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004995 // Check for division by zero.
4996 if (isDiv &&
4997 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004998 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004999 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005000
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005001 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005002}
5003
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005004QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005005 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005006 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5007 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5008 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5009 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5010 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005011
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005012 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005013
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005014 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5015 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005016
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005017 // Check for remainder by zero.
5018 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005019 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5020 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005021
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005022 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005023}
5024
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005025QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005026 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005027 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5028 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5029 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5030 return compType;
5031 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005032
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005033 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005034
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005035 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005036 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5037 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5038 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005039 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005040 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005041
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005042 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5043 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005044 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005045 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5046
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005047 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005048
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005049 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005050 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005051
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005052 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5053 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005054 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5055 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005056 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005057 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005058 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005059
5060 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5061 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5062 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005063 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005064 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5066 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5067 return QualType();
5068 }
5069
5070 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5071 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5072 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005073 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005074 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005075 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005076 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005077 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5078 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005079 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5080 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005081 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005082 return QualType();
5083 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005084 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005085 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005086 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5087 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5088 return QualType();
5089 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005090
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005092 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5093 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5094 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5095 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5096 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005097 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005098 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5099 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005100 return PExp->getType();
5101 }
5102 }
5103
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005104 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005105}
5106
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005107// C99 6.5.6
5108QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005109 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5110 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5111 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5112 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5113 return compType;
5114 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005115
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005116 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005117
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005118 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005119
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005120 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005121 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5122 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005123 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005124 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005125 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005126
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005127 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005128 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005129 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005130
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005131 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005132
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005133 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5134 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5135 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5136 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5137 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5138 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5139 return QualType();
5140 }
5141
5142 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5143 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5144 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5145 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5146 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005147 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005148 return QualType();
5149 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005150
5151 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5152 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5153 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005154 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005155 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005156 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005157 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005158 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005159
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005160 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005161 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005162 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5163 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5164 return QualType();
5165 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005166
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005167 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005168 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5169 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5170 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5171 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5172 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5173 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005174 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005175 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5176
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005177 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005178 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005179 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005180
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005181 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005182 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005183 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005184
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005185 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5186 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5187 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5188 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5189 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5190 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5191 return QualType();
5192 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005193
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005194 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5195 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5196 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5197 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005198 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005199 return QualType();
5200 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005201
5202 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5203 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5204 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5205 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5206 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005207 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5208 << rex->getSourceRange()
5209 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005210 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005211
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005212 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5213 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5214 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5215 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5216 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5217 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5218 return QualType();
5219 }
5220 } else {
5221 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5222 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5223 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5224 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5225 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5226 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5227 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5228 return QualType();
5229 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005230 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005231
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005232 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5233 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5234 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5235 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5236 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005237 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005238 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005239
5240 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005241 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5242 }
5243 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005244
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005245 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005246}
5247
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005248// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005249QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005250 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005251 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5252 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005253 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005254
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005255 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5256 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5257 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5258
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005259 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5260 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005261 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5262 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5263 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5264 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5265 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005266 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005267 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005268 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005269
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005270 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005271
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005272 // Sanity-check shift operands
5273 llvm::APSInt Right;
5274 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005275 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5276 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005277 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005278 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5279 else {
5280 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5281 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5282 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5283 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5284 }
5285 }
5286
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005287 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005288 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005289}
5290
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005291// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005292QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005293 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5294 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5295
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005296 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005297 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005298 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005299
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005300 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5301 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005302
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005303 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5304 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005305 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5306 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5307 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005308 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005309 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005310 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5311 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5312 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005313 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005314 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005315 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl())) {
5316 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5317 << 0 // self-
5318 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5319 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5320 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5321 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5322 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5323 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5324 // what is it always going to eval to?
5325 char always_evals_to;
5326 switch(Opc) {
5327 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5328 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5329 break;
5330 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5331 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5332 break;
5333 default:
5334 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5335 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5336 break;
5337 }
5338 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5339 << 1 // array
5340 << always_evals_to);
5341 }
5342 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005343
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005344 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5345 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5346 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5347 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005348
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005349 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5350 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005351 Expr *literalString = 0;
5352 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005353 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005354 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005355 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005356 literalString = lex;
5357 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005358 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5359 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005360 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005361 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005362 literalString = rex;
5363 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5364 }
5365
5366 if (literalString) {
5367 std::string resultComparison;
5368 switch (Opc) {
5369 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5370 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5371 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5372 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5373 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5374 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5375 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5376 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005377
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005378 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5379 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5380 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005381 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005382 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005383 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005384
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005385 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5386 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5387 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5388 else {
5389 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5390 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5391 }
5392
5393 lType = lex->getType();
5394 rType = rex->getType();
5395
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005396 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005397 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005398
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005399 if (isRelational) {
5400 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005401 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005402 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005403 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005404 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005405 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005406
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005407 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005408 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005409 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005410
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005411 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005412 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005413 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005414 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005415
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005416 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5417 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005418 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005419 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005420 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005421 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005422 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005423
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005424 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005425 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5426 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005427 if (!isRelational &&
5428 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5429 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5430 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005431 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5432 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005433 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5434 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005435 Diag(Loc,
5436 isSFINAEContext()?
5437 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5438 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005439 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005440
5441 if (isSFINAEContext())
5442 return QualType();
5443
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005444 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5445 return ResultTy;
5446 }
5447 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005448 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5449 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5450 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5451 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5452 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5453 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005454 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005455 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005456 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005457 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005458 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005459 if (T.isNull()) {
5460 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5461 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5462 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005463 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005464 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005465 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005466 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005467 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005468 }
5469
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005470 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5471 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005472 return ResultTy;
5473 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005474 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5475 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5476 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5477 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5478 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5479 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5480 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5481 }
5482 } else if (!isRelational &&
5483 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5484 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5485 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5486 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5487 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5488 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5489 }
5490 } else {
5491 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005492 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005493 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005494 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005495 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005496 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005497 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005498 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005499
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005500 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005501 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005502 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005503 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005504 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5505 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005506 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005507 return ResultTy;
5508 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005509 if (LHSIsNull &&
5510 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5511 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005512 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005513 return ResultTy;
5514 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005515
5516 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005517 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005518 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5519 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005520 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5521 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5522 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5523 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5524 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5525 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5526 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5527 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005528 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005529 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005530 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005531 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005532 if (T.isNull()) {
5533 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005534 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005535 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005536 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005537 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005538 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005539 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005540 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005541 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005542
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005543 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5544 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005545 return ResultTy;
5546 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005547
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005548 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005549 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5550 return ResultTy;
5551 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005552
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005553 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005554 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005555 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5556 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005557
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005558 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005559 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005560 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005561 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005562 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005563 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005564 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005565 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005566 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005567 if (!isRelational
5568 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5569 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005570 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005571 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005572 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005573 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005574 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5575 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5576 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005577 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005578 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005579 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005580 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005581
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005582 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005583 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005584 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5585 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005586 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005587 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005588 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005589 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005590
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005591 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5592 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005593 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005594 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005595 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005596 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005597 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005598 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005599 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005600 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005601 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5602 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005603 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005604 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005605 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005606 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005607 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5608 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005609 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005610 bool isError = false;
5611 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5612 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5613 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005614 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005615 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005616 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005617 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5618 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5619 isError = true;
5620 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005621 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005622
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005623 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005624 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005625 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005626 if (isError)
5627 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005628 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005629
5630 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5631 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005632 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005633 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005634 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005635 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005636
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005637 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005638 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5639 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005640 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005641 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005642 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005643 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5644 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005645 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005646 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005647 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005648 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005649}
5650
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005651/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005652/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005653/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5654/// types.
5655QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005656 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005657 bool isRelational) {
5658 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5659 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005660 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005661 if (vType.isNull())
5662 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005663
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005664 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5665 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005666
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005667 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5668 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5669 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005670 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005671 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5672 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5673 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005674 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5675 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5676 << 0 // self-
5677 << 2 // "a constant"
5678 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005679 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005680
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005681 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005682 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5683 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005684 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005685 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005686
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005687 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5688 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5689 // elements for floating point vectors.
5690 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5691 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005692
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005693 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005694 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005695 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005696 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005697 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005698 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5699
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005700 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005701 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005702 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5703}
5704
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005705inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005706 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005707 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005708 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005709
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005710 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005711
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005712 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005713 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005714 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005715}
5716
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005717inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005718 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005719 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5720 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5721 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005722
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005723 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5724 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005725
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005726 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005727 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005728
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005729 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5730 // non-overloadable operands.
5731
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005732 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5733 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005734 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5735 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5736 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005737 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005738
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005739 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5740 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5741 // The result is a bool.
5742 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005743}
5744
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005745/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5746/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5747/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5748///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005749static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005750 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5751 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5752 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5753 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005754 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005755 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5756 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5757 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5758 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005759 }
5760 }
5761 return false;
5762}
5763
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005764/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5765/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5766static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005767 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005768 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005769 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005770 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5771 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005772 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5773 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005774
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005775 unsigned Diag = 0;
5776 bool NeedType = false;
5777 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005778 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005779 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005780 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5781 NeedType = true;
5782 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005783 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005784 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5785 NeedType = true;
5786 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005787 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005788 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5789 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005790 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5791 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005792 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005793 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5794 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005795 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5796 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005797 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5798 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005799 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005800 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005801 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005802 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005803 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5804 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005805 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005806 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5807 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005808 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5809 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5810 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005811 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5812 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5813 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005814 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5815 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5816 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005817 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005818
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005819 SourceRange Assign;
5820 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5821 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005822 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005823 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005824 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005825 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005826 return true;
5827}
5828
5829
5830
5831// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005832QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5833 SourceLocation Loc,
5834 QualType CompoundType) {
5835 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5836 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005837 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005838
5839 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5840 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005841 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005842 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005843 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005844 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005845 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5846 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5847 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5848 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5849 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5850 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5851 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5852 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5853 }
5854 }
5855
5856 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005857 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5858 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5859 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005860 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005861 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005862 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005863 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005864
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005865 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5866 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5867 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005868 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005869 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5870 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5871 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5872 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5873 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005874 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005875 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005876 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5877 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5878 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005879 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5880 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005881 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5882 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5883 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005884 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005885 }
5886 } else {
5887 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005888 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005889 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005890
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005891 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005892 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005893 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005894
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005895 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5896 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005897 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005898 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5899 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005900 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005901 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005902 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005903}
5904
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005905// C99 6.5.17
5906QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00005907 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
5908
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005909 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005910 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5911 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5912 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005913
5914 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5915 // incomplete in C++).
5916
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005917 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005918}
5919
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005920/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5921/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005922QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005923 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005924 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5925 return Context.DependentTy;
5926
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005927 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5928 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005929
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005930 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5931 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5932 if (!isInc) {
5933 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5934 return QualType();
5935 }
5936 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5937 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5938 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005939 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005940 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5941 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005942
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005943 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005944 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005945 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5946 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5947 << Op->getSourceRange();
5948 return QualType();
5949 }
5950
5951 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005952 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005953 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005954 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5955 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5956 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5957 return QualType();
5958 }
5959
5960 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005961 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005962 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005963 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005964 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005965 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005966 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005967 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005968 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005969 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5970 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5971 return QualType();
5972 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005973 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005974 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5975 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005976 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005977 } else {
5978 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005979 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005980 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005981 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005982 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005983 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005984 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005985 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005986 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5987 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5988 // operand.
5989 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5990 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005991}
5992
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005993/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005994/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005995/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5996/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5997/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5998/// - &(x) => x
5999/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6000/// - &s.xx => s
6001/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6002/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6003/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6004/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006005static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006006 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006007 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006008 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006009 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006010 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6011 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6012 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006013 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006014 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006015 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006016 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006017 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006018 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6019 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006020 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6021 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6022 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6023 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6024 }
6025 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006026 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006027 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6028 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006029
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006030 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006031 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6032 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6033 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6034 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6035 default:
6036 return 0;
6037 }
6038 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006039 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006040 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006041 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006042 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6043 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006044 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006045 default:
6046 return 0;
6047 }
6048}
6049
6050/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006051/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006052/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006053/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006054/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006055/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006056/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006057QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006058 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6059 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6060
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006061 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6062 return Context.DependentTy;
6063
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006064 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6065 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6066 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6067 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6068 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6069 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6070 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6071 }
6072 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6073 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6074 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006075 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006076 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006077
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006078 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6079 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6080 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6081 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6082 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6083 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6084 // branch of the if, below.
6085 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6086 << dcl;
6087 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6088
6089 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6090 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6091 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6092 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006093 }
6094
6095 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006096 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6097 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6098 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6099 if (isSFINAEContext())
6100 return QualType();
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006101 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006102 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006103 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006104 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006105 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006106 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006107 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006108 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6109 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006110 return QualType();
6111 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006112 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006113 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6114 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6115 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006116 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006117 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006118 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006119 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006120 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006121 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006122 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6123 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6125 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6126 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006127 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6128 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006129 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6130 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006131 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6132 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006133 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006134 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006135 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6136 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006137 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006138 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6139 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006140 return QualType();
6141 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006142 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006143 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006144 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006145 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006146 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6147 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006148 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006149 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006150 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6151 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006152 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006153 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6154 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6155 return QualType();
6156 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006157
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006158 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6159 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006160 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006161 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006162 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006163 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006164 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006165 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6166 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006167 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6168 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6169 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006170 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006171 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006172
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006173 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6174 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6175 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6176 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6177 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6178 }
6179
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006180 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006181 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006182}
6183
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006184/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006185QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006186 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6187 return Context.DependentTy;
6188
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006189 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006190 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6191 QualType Result;
6192
6193 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6194 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6195 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6196 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6197 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6198 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6199 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6200 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6201 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006202
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006203 if (Result.isNull()) {
6204 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6205 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6206 return QualType();
6207 }
6208
6209 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006210}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006211
6212static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6213 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6214 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6215 switch (Kind) {
6216 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006217 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6218 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006219 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6220 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6221 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6222 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6223 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6224 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6225 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6226 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6227 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6228 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6229 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6230 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6231 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6232 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6233 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6234 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6235 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6236 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6237 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6238 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6239 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6240 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6241 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6242 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6243 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6244 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6245 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6246 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6247 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6248 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6249 }
6250 return Opc;
6251}
6252
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006253static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6254 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6255 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6256 switch (Kind) {
6257 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6258 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6259 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6260 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6261 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6262 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6263 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6264 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6265 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006266 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6267 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006268 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006269 }
6270 return Opc;
6271}
6272
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006273/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6274/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6275/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006276Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6277 unsigned Op,
6278 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006279 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006280 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006281 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6282 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6283 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006284
6285 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006286 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6287 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6288 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006289 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6290 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6291 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6292 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6293 break;
6294 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006295 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006296 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6297 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006298 break;
6299 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6300 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6301 break;
6302 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6303 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6304 break;
6305 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6306 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6307 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006308 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006309 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6310 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6311 break;
6312 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6313 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6314 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6315 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006316 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006317 break;
6318 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6319 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006320 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006321 break;
6322 case BinaryOperator::And:
6323 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6324 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6325 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6326 break;
6327 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6328 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6329 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6330 break;
6331 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6332 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006333 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6334 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006335 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6336 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6337 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006338 break;
6339 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006340 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6341 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6342 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6343 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006344 break;
6345 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006346 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6347 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6348 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006349 break;
6350 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006351 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6352 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6353 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006354 break;
6355 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6356 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006357 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6358 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6359 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6360 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006361 break;
6362 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6363 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6364 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006365 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6366 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6367 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6368 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006369 break;
6370 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6371 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6372 break;
6373 }
6374 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006375 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006376 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006377 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6378 else
6379 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006380 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6381 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006382}
6383
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006384/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6385/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006386static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6387 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006388 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6389 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6390 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006391 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006392 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6393
6394 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6395 return;
6396
6397 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6398 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6399 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006400 return;
6401 }
6402
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006403 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6404 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006405 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006406
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006407 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006408 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006409
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006410 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6411 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6412 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6413 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006414 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006415 return;
6416 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006417
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006418 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006419 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6420 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006421}
6422
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006423/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6424/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6425/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6426/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006427static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6428 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006429 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6430 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6431 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6432 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006433 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006434 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006435 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6436
6437 // Subs are not binary operators.
6438 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6439 return;
6440
6441 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6442 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006443 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6444 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006445 return;
6446
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006447 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006448 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006449 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006450 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6451 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006452 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006453 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006454 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6455 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6456 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6457 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006458 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006459 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006460 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006461 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6462 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006463 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006464 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006465 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6466 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6467 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6468 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006469}
6470
6471/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6472/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6473/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6474static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6475 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006476 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006477 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6478}
6479
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006480// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006481Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6482 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6483 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006484 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006485 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006486
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006487 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6488 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006489
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006490 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6491 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6492
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006493 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6494}
6495
6496Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6497 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6498 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006499 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006500 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006501 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6502 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6503 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6504 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6505 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006506 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006507 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006508 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6509 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6510 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006511
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006512 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6513 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006514 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006515 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006516
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006517 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006518 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006519}
6520
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006521Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006522 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006523 ExprArg InputArg) {
6524 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006525
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006526 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006527 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006528 QualType resultType;
6529 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006530 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6531 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6532 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006533
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006534 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6535 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006536 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6537 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006538 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006539 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006540 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6541 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6542 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006543 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006544 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006545 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006546 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006547 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006548 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006549 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006550 break;
6551 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6552 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006553 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6554 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006555 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6556 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006557 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6558 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006559 break;
6560 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6561 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6562 break;
6563 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6564 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6565 resultType->isPointerType())
6566 break;
6567
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006568 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6569 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006570 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006571 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6572 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006573 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6574 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006575 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6576 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6577 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006578 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006579 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006580 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006581 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6582 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006583 break;
6584 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006585 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006586 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006587 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006588 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6589 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006590 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006591 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6592 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006593 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006594 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6595 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006596 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006597 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006598 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006599 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006600 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006601 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006602 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006603 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006604 }
6605 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006606 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006607
6608 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006609 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006610}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006611
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006612Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6613 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6614 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006615 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006616 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6617 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006618 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6619 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6620 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6621 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006622 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006623 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006624 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6625 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6626 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006627
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006628 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6629 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006630
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006631 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6632}
6633
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006634// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6635Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6636 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6637 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6638}
6639
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006640/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006641Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6642 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6643 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006644 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006645 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006646
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006647 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6648 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006649 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006650 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006651
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006652 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006653 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6654 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006655}
6656
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006657Sema::OwningExprResult
6658Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6659 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6660 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006661 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6662 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6663
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006664 bool isFileScope
6665 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006666 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006667 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006668
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006669 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6670 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6671 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006672
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006673 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6674 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6675 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006676
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006677 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6678 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6679 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6680 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6681 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006682
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006683 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006684 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006685 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006686
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006687 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6688 // expressions are not lvalues.
6689
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006690 substmt.release();
6691 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006692}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006693
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006694Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6695 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006696 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6697 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006698 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6699 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006700 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006701 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006702
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006703 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6704 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6705 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006706 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006707 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6708 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6709
6710 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6711 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6712 if (!Dependent
6713 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6714 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6715 << TypeRange))
6716 return ExprError();
6717
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006718 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6719 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006720 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6721 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006722 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006723 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6724 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006725
6726 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6727 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6728 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6729 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6730 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6731 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6732 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6733 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6734 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6735 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6736 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6737 if(!AT)
6738 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6739 << CurrentType);
6740 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6741 } else
6742 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6743
6744 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6745 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6746 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6747 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6748 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6749 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6750 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6751 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6752
6753 // Record this array index.
6754 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6755 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6756 continue;
6757 }
6758
6759 // Offset of a field.
6760 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6761 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6762 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6763 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6764 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6765 continue;
6766 }
6767
6768 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6769 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6770 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6771 return ExprError();
6772
6773 // Look for the designated field.
6774 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6775 if (!RC)
6776 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6777 << CurrentType);
6778 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6779
6780 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6781 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6782 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6783 // (clause 9).
6784 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6785 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6786 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6787 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6788 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6789 << CurrentType))
6790 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6791 }
6792
6793 // Look for the field.
6794 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6795 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6796 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6797 if (!MemberDecl)
6798 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6799 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6800 OC.LocEnd));
6801
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006802 // C99 7.17p3:
6803 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6804 //
6805 // We diagnose this as an error.
6806 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6807 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6808 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6809 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6810 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6811 return ExprError();
6812 }
6813
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006814 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6815 // the base class indirections.
6816 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6817 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6818 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6819 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6820 Paths)) {
6821 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6822 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6823 B != BEnd; ++B)
6824 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6825 }
6826
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006827 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006828 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006829 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6830 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6831 unsigned n = Path.size();
6832 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6833 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6834 } else {
6835 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6836 }
6837 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6838 }
6839
6840 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6841 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6842 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6843}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006844
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006845Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6846 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6847 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6848 TypeTy *argty,
6849 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6850 unsigned NumComponents,
6851 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6852
6853 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6854 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6855 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6856 return ExprError();
6857
6858 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6859 if (!ArgTInfo)
6860 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6861
6862 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6863 RPLoc);
6864 }
6865
6866 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6867 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6868
6869 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6870
6871 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6872 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6873 // a struct/union/class.
6874 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6875 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6876
6877 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6878 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6879
6880 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6881 // the offsetof designators.
6882 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6883 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6884 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6885 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6886
6887 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6888 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6889 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6890 // a system header!
6891 if (NumComponents != 1)
6892 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6893 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6894
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006895 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006896 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006897
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006898 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6899 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6900 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006902 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6903 // leaks like a sieve.
6904 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6905 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6906 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6907 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6908 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6909 if (!AT) {
6910 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006911 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006912 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006913 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006914
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006915 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006916
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006917 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6918 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006919 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006920
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006921 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6922 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006923 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006924 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006925 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006926 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006927 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6928
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006929 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6930 OC.LocEnd);
6931 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006932 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006933
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006934 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006935 if (!RC) {
6936 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006937 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006938 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006939 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006940
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006941 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6942 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006943 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006944 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6945 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6946 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006947 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6948 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006949 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006950 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006951
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006952 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6953 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006954
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006955 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006956 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006957 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006958 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006959 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6960
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006961 // C99 7.17p3:
6962 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6963 //
6964 // We diagnose this as an error.
6965 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6966 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6967 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6968 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6969 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6970 return ExprError();
6971 }
6972
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006973 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6974 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006975 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006976 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006977 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006978 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006979 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6980 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006981 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6982 // doesn't matter here.
6983 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006984 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006985 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006986 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006987 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006988
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006989 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6990 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006991}
6992
6993
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006994Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6995 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6996 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006997 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6998 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6999 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007000
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007001 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007002
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007003 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7004 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7005 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7006 return ExprError();
7007 }
7008
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007009 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
7010 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007011}
7012
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007013Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7014 ExprArg cond,
7015 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7016 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7017 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7018 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7019 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007020
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007021 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7022
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007023 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007024 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007025 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007026 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007027 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007028 } else {
7029 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7030 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7031 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7032 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007033 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7034 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7035 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007036
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007037 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7038 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007039 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7040 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007041 }
7042
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007043 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7044 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007045 resType, RPLoc,
7046 resType->isDependentType(),
7047 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007048}
7049
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007050//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7051// Clang Extensions.
7052//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7053
7054/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007055void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007056 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7057 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7058 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7059 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007060}
7061
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007062void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007063 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007064 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007065
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007066 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007067 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007068 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007069
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007070 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007071 QualType RetTy;
7072 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007073 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007074 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007075 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007076 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7077 } else {
7078 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007079 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007080 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007081
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007082 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007083
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007084 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7085 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7086 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007087 return;
7088 }
7089
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007090 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7091 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7092 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7093 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7094 return;
7095 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007096
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007097 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007098 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7099 // ^ * { ... }
7100 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007101 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7102 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007103
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007104 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007105 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007106 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7107 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7108 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7109 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007110 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7111 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7112 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7113 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7114 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007115 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007116 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007117
7118 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7119 // ^ fntype { ... }
7120 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7121 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7122 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7123 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7124 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7125 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7126 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007127 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007128 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007129 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007130
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007131 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7132 if (!Params.empty())
7133 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007134
7135 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007136 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007137
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7140 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7141 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7142 }
7143
7144 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7145 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007146 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007147 return;
7148
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007149 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7150 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7151
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007152 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007153 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7154 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7155
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007156 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007157 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7158 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7159 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7160
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007161 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007162 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007163 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007164}
7165
7166/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7167/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7168void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007169 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007170 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007171 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007172 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007173}
7174
7175/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7176/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007177Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7178 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007179 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7180 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7181 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007182
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007183 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007184
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007185 PopDeclContext();
7186
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007187 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007188 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7189 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007190
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007191 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007192 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007193
7194 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7195 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7196 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7197
7198 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7199 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7200
7201 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7202 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7203 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7204 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7205
7206 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7207 // preserve its sugar structure.
7208 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7209 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7210 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7211
7212 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7213 } else {
7214 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7215 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7216 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7217 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7218 FPT->isVariadic(),
7219 /*quals*/ 0,
7220 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7221 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7222 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7223 FPT->exception_begin(),
7224 Ext);
7225 }
7226
7227 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7228 } else {
7229 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7230 false, false, 0, 0,
7231 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7232 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007233
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007234 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007235 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7236 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007237 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007238
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007239 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007240 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007241 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007242
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007243 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007244
7245 bool Good = true;
7246 // Check goto/label use.
7247 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7248 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7249 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7250
7251 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7252 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7253 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7254 continue;
7255
7256 // Emit error.
7257 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7258 Good = false;
7259 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007260 if (!Good) {
7261 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007262 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007263 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007264
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007265 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007266 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7267 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7268 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007269
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007270 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7271 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007272 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007273 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007274}
7275
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007276Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7277 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7278 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007279 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007280 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7281 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007282
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007283 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007284
7285 // Get the va_list type
7286 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007287 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7288 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7289 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7290 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007291 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007292 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7293 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7294 } else {
7295 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7296 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007297 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007298 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007299 return ExprError();
7300 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007301
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007302 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7303 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007304 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7305 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007306 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007307 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007308
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007309 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007310 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007311
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007312 expr.release();
7313 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7314 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007315}
7316
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007317Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007318 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7319 // pointers on the target.
7320 QualType Ty;
7321 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7322 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7323 else
7324 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7325
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007326 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007327}
7328
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007329static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007330 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007331 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7332 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007333
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007334 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7335 if (!PT)
7336 return;
7337
7338 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7339 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7340 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7341 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7342 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7343 return;
7344 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007345
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007346 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7347 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7348 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7349 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007350
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007351 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007352}
7353
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007354bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7355 SourceLocation Loc,
7356 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007357 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7358 bool *Complained) {
7359 if (Complained)
7360 *Complained = false;
7361
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007362 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7363 bool isInvalid = false;
7364 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007365 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007366
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007367 switch (ConvTy) {
7368 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7369 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007370 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007371 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7372 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007373 case IntToPointer:
7374 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7375 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007376 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007377 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007378 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7379 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007380 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7381 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7382 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007383 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7384 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7385 break;
7386 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007387 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7388 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7389 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7390 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7391 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7392 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7393 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7394 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7395 // C++ semantics.
7396 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7397 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7398 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007399 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7400 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007401 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007402 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007403 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007404 case IntToBlockPointer:
7405 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7406 break;
7407 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007408 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007409 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007410 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007411 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007412 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7413 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7414 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007415 case IncompatibleVectors:
7416 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7417 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007418 case Incompatible:
7419 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7420 isInvalid = true;
7421 break;
7422 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007423
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007424 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7425 switch (Action) {
7426 case AA_Assigning:
7427 case AA_Initializing:
7428 // The destination type comes first.
7429 FirstType = DstType;
7430 SecondType = SrcType;
7431 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007432
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007433 case AA_Returning:
7434 case AA_Passing:
7435 case AA_Converting:
7436 case AA_Sending:
7437 case AA_Casting:
7438 // The source type comes first.
7439 FirstType = SrcType;
7440 SecondType = DstType;
7441 break;
7442 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007443
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007444 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007445 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007446 if (Complained)
7447 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007448 return isInvalid;
7449}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007450
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007451bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007452 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7453 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7454 if (Result)
7455 *Result = ICEResult;
7456 return false;
7457 }
7458
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007459 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7460
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007461 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007462 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7463 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7464
7465 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7466 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7467 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7468 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7469 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7470 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7471 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007472
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007473 return true;
7474 }
7475
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007476 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7477 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007478
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007479 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7480 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7481 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007482
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007483 if (Result)
7484 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7485 return false;
7486}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007487
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007488void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007489Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007490 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7491 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007492}
7493
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007494void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007495Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7496 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7497 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7498 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007499
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007500 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7501 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7502 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7503 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7504 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007505 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007506 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7507 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7508 I != IEnd; ++I)
7509 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7510 }
7511
7512 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7513 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7514 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7515 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7516 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7517 I != IEnd; ++I)
7518 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7519 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007520 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007521
7522 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7523 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7524 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7525 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007526 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007527 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7528 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7529 ExprTemporaries.end());
7530
7531 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7532 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007533}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007534
7535/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7536///
7537/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7538/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7539/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7540/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7541///
7542/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7543///
7544/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7545void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7546 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007547
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007548 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007549 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007550
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007551 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7552 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7553 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7554 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007555 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007556 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007557 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007558 return;
7559 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007560
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007561 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7562 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007563
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007564 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7565 // an instantiation.
7566 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7567 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007568
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007569 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007570 case Unevaluated:
7571 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7572 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007573
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007574 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7575 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7576 // "used"; handle this below.
7577 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007578
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007579 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7580 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7581 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7582 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007583 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007584 return;
7585 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007586
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007587 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007588 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007589 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007590 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007591 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007592 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007593 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007594 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007595 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007596 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7597 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007598
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007599 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007600 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007601 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007602 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007603 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7604 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007605 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7606 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7607 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007608 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007609 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007610 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7611 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007612 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007613 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007614 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007615 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007616 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007617 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7618 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7619 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7620 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7621 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007622 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007623 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007624 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007625 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007626 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7627 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7628 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007629 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007630 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007631 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7632 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007633
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007634 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7635 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7636 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7637 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7638 Loc));
7639 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007640 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007641 Loc));
7642 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007643 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007644
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007645 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007646 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007647
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007648 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007649 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007650
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007651 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007652 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007653 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007654 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7655 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7656 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7657 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7658 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7659 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7660 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7661 }
7662 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007663
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007664 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007665
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007666 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007667 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007668 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007669}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007670
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007671namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007672 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007673 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007674 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007675 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7676 Sema &S;
7677 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007678
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007679 public:
7680 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007681
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007682 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007683
7684 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7685 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007686 };
7687}
7688
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007689bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7690 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007691 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7692 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7693 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007694
7695 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007696}
7697
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007698bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007699 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7700 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7701 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007702 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7703 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007704 }
7705
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007706 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007707}
7708
7709void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7710 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007711 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007712}
7713
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007714/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7715/// of the program being compiled.
7716///
7717/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007718/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007719/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7720/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7721/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7722/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007723/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007724/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007725///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007726/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7727/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7728/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7729/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007730bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007731 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7732 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7733 case Unevaluated:
7734 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7735 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007736
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007737 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7738 Diag(Loc, PD);
7739 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007740
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007741 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7742 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7743 break;
7744 }
7745
7746 return false;
7747}
7748
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007749bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7750 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7751 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7752 return false;
7753
7754 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7755 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7756 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7757 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007758
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007759 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007760 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007761 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7762 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007763 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007764 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7765 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7766 return true;
7767
7768 return false;
7769}
7770
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007771// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7772// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7773void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7774 SourceLocation Loc;
7775
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007776 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7777
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007778 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7779 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7780 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7781 return;
7782
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007783 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7784 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7785 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7786 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7787
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007788 // self = [<foo> init...]
7789 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7790 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7791 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7792
7793 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7794 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7795 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7796 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7797 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007798
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007799 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7800 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7801 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7802 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7803 return;
7804
7805 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7806 } else {
7807 // Not an assignment.
7808 return;
7809 }
7810
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007811 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007812 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007813
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007814 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007815 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007816 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007817 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7818 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7819 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007820}
7821
7822bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7823 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7824
7825 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007826 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007827
7828 QualType T = E->getType();
7829
7830 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7831 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7832 return true;
7833 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7834 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7835 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7836 return true;
7837 }
7838 }
7839
7840 return false;
7841}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007842
7843Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7844 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007845 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7846 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007847 return ExprError();
7848
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007849 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7850 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7851 return ExprError();
7852 }
7853
7854 return Owned(Sub);
7855}